blob: a35ef318da100b51f66c5515f6660fa2014ed90a [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkb75190d2012-01-19 10:58:21 +01002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2012
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
5# See file CREDITS for list of people who contributed to this
6# project.
7#
8# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
9# modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
10# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of
11# the License, or (at your option) any later version.
12#
13# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16# GNU General Public License for more details.
17#
18# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
20# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston,
21# MA 02111-1307 USA
22#
23
24Summary:
25========
26
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000027This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000028Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
29processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
30initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
31code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000032
33The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
35header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000036support booting of Linux images.
37
38Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
39configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
40implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
41add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
42code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
43load and run it dynamically.
44
45
46Status:
47=======
48
49In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000051"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
52
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000053In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010054who contributed the specific port. The MAINTAINERS file lists board
55maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
Robert P. J. Dayadb9d852012-11-14 02:03:20 +000057Note: There is no CHANGELOG file in the actual U-Boot source tree;
58it can be created dynamically from the Git log using:
59
60 make CHANGELOG
61
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000062
63Where to get help:
64==================
65
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000066In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
67U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050068<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
69on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
70Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
71http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000072
73
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010074Where to get source code:
75=========================
76
77The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
78git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
79http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
80
81The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020082any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010083available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
84directory.
85
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010086Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010087ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
88
89
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000090Where we come from:
91===================
92
93- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000094- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000095- clean up code
96- make it easier to add custom boards
97- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
98- extend functions, especially:
99 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
100 * S-Record download
101 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200102 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000103- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000104- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000105- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +0200106- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000107
108
109Names and Spelling:
110===================
111
112The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
113"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
114in source files etc.). Example:
115
116 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
117
118File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
119
120 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
121
122 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
123
124Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
125the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
126
127 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
128 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000129
130
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000131Versioning:
132===========
133
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200134Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
135were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
136into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
137names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
138Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
139releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000140
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200141Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000142 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200143 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
144 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000145
146
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000147Directory Hierarchy:
148====================
149
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500150/arch Architecture specific files
151 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
152 /cpu CPU specific files
153 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
154 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000155 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200156 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
157 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500158 /arm925t Files specific to ARM 925 CPUs
159 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
160 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
161 /ixp Files specific to Intel XScale IXP CPUs
162 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
163 /s3c44b0 Files specific to Samsung S3C44B0 CPUs
164 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
165 /lib Architecture specific library files
166 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
167 /cpu CPU specific files
168 /lib Architecture specific library files
169 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
170 /cpu CPU specific files
171 /lib Architecture specific library files
Graeme Russfea25722011-04-13 19:43:28 +1000172 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500173 /cpu CPU specific files
174 /lib Architecture specific library files
175 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
176 /cpu CPU specific files
177 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
178 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
179 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
180 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
181 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
182 /lib Architecture specific library files
183 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
184 /cpu CPU specific files
185 /lib Architecture specific library files
186 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
187 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200188 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Xiangfu Liu80421fc2011-10-12 12:24:06 +0800189 /xburst Files specific to Ingenic XBurst CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500190 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000191 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
192 /cpu CPU specific files
193 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
194 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500195 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
196 /cpu CPU specific files
197 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200198 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500199 /cpu CPU specific files
200 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
201 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
202 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
203 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
204 /mpc8220 Files specific to Freescale MPC8220 CPUs
205 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
206 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
207 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
208 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
209 /lib Architecture specific library files
210 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
211 /cpu CPU specific files
212 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
213 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
214 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
215 /lib Architecture specific library files
216 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
217 /cpu CPU specific files
218 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
219 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
220 /lib Architecture specific library files
221/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
222/board Board dependent files
223/common Misc architecture independent functions
224/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
225/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
226/drivers Commonly used device drivers
227/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
228/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
229/include Header Files
230/lib Files generic to all architectures
231 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
232 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
233 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
234/net Networking code
235/post Power On Self Test
236/rtc Real Time Clock drivers
237/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000238
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000239Software Configuration:
240=======================
241
242Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
243rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
244
245There are two classes of configuration variables:
246
247* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
248 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
249 "CONFIG_".
250
251* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
252 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
253 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200254 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000255
256Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
257identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
258do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
259links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
260as an example here.
261
262
263Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
264---------------------------------------------------
265
266For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
267configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_config".
268
269Example: For a TQM823L module type:
270
271 cd u-boot
272 make TQM823L_config
273
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200274For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000275e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_config". And also configure the cogent
276directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
277
278
279Configuration Options:
280----------------------
281
282Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
283such information is kept in a configuration file
284"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
285
286Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
287"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
288
289
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000290Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
291kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
292build a config tool - later.
293
294
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000295The following options need to be configured:
296
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500297- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000298
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500299- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200300
301- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100302 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000303
304- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
305 Define exactly one of
306 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
307--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
308 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
309 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
310
311- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
312 Define exactly one of
313 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
314
315- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
316 Define one or more of
317 CONFIG_CMA302
318
319- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
320 Define one or more of
321 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200322 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000323 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
324
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000325- Board flavour: (if CONFIG_MPC8260ADS is defined)
326 CONFIG_ADSTYPE
327 Possible values are:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200328 CONFIG_SYS_8260ADS - original MPC8260ADS
329 CONFIG_SYS_8266ADS - MPC8266ADS
330 CONFIG_SYS_PQ2FADS - PQ2FADS-ZU or PQ2FADS-VR
331 CONFIG_SYS_8272ADS - MPC8272ADS
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000332
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530333- Marvell Family Member
334 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
335 multiple fs option at one time
336 for marvell soc family
337
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000338- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000339 Define exactly one of
340 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000341
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200342- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000343 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
344 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000345 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
346 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000347 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
348 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000349
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000350- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200351 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
352 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000353 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000354 See doc/README.MPC866
355
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200356 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000357
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000358 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
359 of relying on the correctness of the configured
360 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
361 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
362 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200363 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000364
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100365 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
366
367 Define this option if you want to enable the
368 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
369
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600370- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sunffd06e02012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000371 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
372
373 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
374 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
375 compliance, among other possible reasons.
376
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600377 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
378
379 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
380 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
381 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
382
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500383 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
384
385 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
386 tree nodes for the given platform.
387
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000388 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
389
390 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
391 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
392 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
393 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
394 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
395 purpose.
396
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000397 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
398
399 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
400 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
401 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
402
403 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
404 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
405
406 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
407 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
408
409 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
410 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
411 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
412 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
413
414 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
415 this erratum.
416
417 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
418
419 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
420 according to the A004510 workaround.
421
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000422- Generic CPU options:
423 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
424
425 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
426 values is arch specific.
427
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100428- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200429 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100430
431 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
432 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
433 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
434
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200435 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200436
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100437 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
438 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200439 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100440 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200441
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200442- MIPS CPU options:
443 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
444
445 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
446 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
447 relocation.
448
449 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
450
451 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
452 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
453 Possible values are:
454 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
455 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
456 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
457 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
458 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
459 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
460 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
461 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
462
463 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
464
465 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
466 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
467
468 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
469
470 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
471 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
472 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
473
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000474- ARM options:
475 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
476
477 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
478 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
479
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000480 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
481
482 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
483 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
484 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
485 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
486 GCC.
487
Stephen Warrenc5d47522013-03-04 13:29:40 +0000488 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_716044
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000489 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_742230
490 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_743622
491 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_751472
492
493 If set, the workarounds for these ARM errata are applied early
494 during U-Boot startup. Note that these options force the
495 workarounds to be applied; no CPU-type/version detection
496 exists, unlike the similar options in the Linux kernel. Do not
497 set these options unless they apply!
498
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000499- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000500 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
501
502 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
503 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
504 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
505 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
506 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
507 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
508 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000509 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100510 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000511 default environment.
512
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000513 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
514
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200515 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000516 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
517 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
518
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400519 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200520
521 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400522 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
523 concepts).
524
525 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
526 * New libfdt-based support
527 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500528 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400529
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200530 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
531 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
532 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
533 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200534 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600535 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200536
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200537 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
538 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500539
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600540 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
541
542 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
543 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000544
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500545 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
546
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200547 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500548 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
549
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200550 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
551
552 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
553 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
554 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
555 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
556 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
557 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
558
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000559 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
560
561 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
562 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
563 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
564 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
565 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
566 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
567 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
568
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100569- vxWorks boot parameters:
570
571 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
572 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
573 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
574
575 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
576 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
577 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
578 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
579
580 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
581
582 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
583
584 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
585 the defaults discussed just above.
586
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000587- Cache Configuration:
588 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
589 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
590 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
591
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000592- Cache Configuration for ARM:
593 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
594 controller
595 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
596 controller register space
597
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000598- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200599 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000600
601 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
602
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200603 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000604
605 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
606
607 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
608
609 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
610 the clock speed of the UARTs.
611
612 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
613
614 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
615 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
616 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
617
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000618 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
619
620 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
621 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
622 this variable to initialize the extra register.
623
624 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
625
626 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
627 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
628 variable to flush the UART at init time.
629
Javier Martinez Canillas7de0fe12013-01-07 01:35:20 +0000630 CONFIG_SYS_NS16550_BROKEN_TEMT
631
632 16550 UART set the Transmitter Empty (TEMT) Bit when all output
633 has finished and the transmitter is totally empty. U-Boot waits
634 for this bit to be set to initialize the serial console. On some
635 broken platforms this bit is not set in SPL making U-Boot to
636 hang while waiting for TEMT. Define this option to avoid it.
637
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000638
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000639- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000640 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
641 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
642 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
643 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000644
645 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
646 port routines must be defined elsewhere
647 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
648
649 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
650 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000651 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000652 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
653 (default big endian)
654 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
655 rectangle fill
656 (cf. smiLynxEM)
657 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
658 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
659 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
660 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000661 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
662 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000663 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
664 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000665 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000666 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
667 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
668 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
669 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
670 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
671 (i.e. i8042_getc)
672 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
673 (requires blink timer
674 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200675 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000676 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
677 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500678 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000679 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
680 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000681 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
682 linux_logo.h for logo.
683 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000684 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200685 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000686 the logo
687
Pali Rohár33a35bb2012-10-19 13:30:09 +0000688 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE_ANSI is defined, console will support
689 a limited number of ANSI escape sequences (cursor control,
690 erase functions and limited graphics rendition control).
691
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000692 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
693 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
694 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000695
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000696 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
697 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
698 the "silent" environment variable. See
699 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000700
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000701- Console Baudrate:
702 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
703 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200704 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
705 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000706
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100707- Console Rx buffer length
708 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
709 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100710 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100711 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
712 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
713 the SMC.
714
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000715- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200716 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
717 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
718 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
719 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
720 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
721 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
722 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200723 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200724 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000725
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200726 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
727 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000728
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000729- Safe printf() functions
730 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
731 the printf() functions. These are defined in
732 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
733 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
734 If this option is not given then these functions will
735 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
736 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
737
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000738- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
739 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
740 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
Joe Hershberger93d72122012-08-17 10:53:12 +0000741 set to -2 to autoboot with no delay and not check for abort
742 (even when CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK is defined).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000743
744 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
745 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
746 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
747 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
748 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
749 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
750 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
751 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
752 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
753 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
754 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
755 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
756
757- Autoboot Command:
758 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
759 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
760 define a command string that is automatically executed
761 when no character is read on the console interface
762 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
763
764 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000765 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
766 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
767 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000768
769 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000770 The value of these goes into the environment as
771 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
772 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200773 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000774
775- Pre-Boot Commands:
776 CONFIG_PREBOOT
777
778 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
779 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
780 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
781 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
782 entering interactive mode.
783
784 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
785 automatically generated or modified. For an example
786 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
787 modified when the user holds down a certain
788 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
789 booting the systems
790
791- Serial Download Echo Mode:
792 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
793 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
794 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
795 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
796 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
797 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
798 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
799
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500800- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000801 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
802 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200803 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000804
805- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500806 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
807 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +0000808 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
809 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500810 and augmenting with additional #define's
811 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000812
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500813 The default command configuration includes all commands
814 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000815
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500816 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500817 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
818 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
819 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
820 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
821 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
822 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
823 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500824 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500825 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
826 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
827 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600828 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
829 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
830 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
831 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500832 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
833 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500834 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500835 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
836 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Joe Hershberger5e2b3e02012-12-11 22:16:25 -0600837 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_CALLBACK * display details about env callbacks
Joe Hershbergerfffad712012-12-11 22:16:33 -0600838 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_FLAGS * display details about env flags
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500839 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000840 CONFIG_CMD_EXT2 * ext2 command support
841 CONFIG_CMD_EXT4 * ext4 command support
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500842 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500843 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000844 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500845 CONFIG_CMD_FDOS * Dos diskette Support
846 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
847 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Anton Staaf53fdc7e2012-12-05 14:46:29 +0000848 CONFIG_CMD_GETTIME * Get time since boot
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -0500849 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +0000850 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +0000851 CONFIG_CMD_HASH * calculate hash / digest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500852 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
853 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
854 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
855 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
Vipin Kumar8fdf1e02012-12-16 22:32:48 +0000856 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all images found in NOR flash
857 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS_NAND List all images found in NAND flash
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500858 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500859 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Joe Hershbergerc167cc02012-10-03 11:15:51 +0000860 CONFIG_CMD_INI * import data from an ini file into the env
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500861 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
862 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
863 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
864 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Mike Frysinger1ba7fd22010-12-26 12:34:49 -0500865 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +0000866 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
867 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500868 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
869 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400870 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM print md5 message digest
871 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Simon Glass15a33e42012-11-30 13:01:20 +0000872 CONFIG_CMD_MEMINFO * Display detailed memory information
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500873 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
Wolfgang Denka2681702013-03-08 10:51:32 +0000874 loop, loopw
875 CONFIG_CMD_MEMTEST mtest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500876 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
877 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
878 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +0100879 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500880 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
881 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600882 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000883 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500884 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
885 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
886 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
887 host
888 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
Kenneth Watersff048ea2012-12-05 14:46:30 +0000889 CONFIG_CMD_READ * Read raw data from partition
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500890 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
891 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
Simon Glassd3049312012-12-26 09:53:36 +0000892 CONFIG_CMD_SANDBOX * sb command to access sandbox features
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500893 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
894 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
895 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
896 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
897 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
898 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -0700899 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Alexander Hollerc6b1ee62011-01-18 09:48:08 +0100900 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400901 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +0200902 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500903 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +0000904 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +0000905 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Joe Hershbergerda83bcd2012-10-03 12:14:57 +0000906 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time (ARM specific)
907 CONFIG_CMD_TIMER * access to the system tick timer
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500908 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500909 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +0000910 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000911
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000912
913 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
914 support you can write:
915
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500916 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
917 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000918
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400919 Other Commands:
920 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000921
922 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500923 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000924 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
925 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
926 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
927 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
928 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
929 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000930
931
932 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
933
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000934- Device tree:
935 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
936 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
937 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
938 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
939 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
940 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
941
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000942 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
943 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +0000944
945 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
946 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
947 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
948 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
949 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
950 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000951
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000952 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
953 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
954 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
955 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
956
957 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
958
959 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
960 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
961 still use the individual files if you need something more
962 exotic.
963
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000964- Watchdog:
965 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
966 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000967 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
968 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
969 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
970 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
971 available, then no further board specific code should
972 be needed to use it.
973
974 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
975 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
976 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
977 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000978
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000979- U-Boot Version:
980 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
981 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
982 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
983 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e52012-08-13 15:01:14 +0200984 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
985 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000986
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000987- Real-Time Clock:
988
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500989 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000990 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
991 following options:
992
993 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
994 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +0000995 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000996 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +0000997 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000998 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +0000999 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +00001000 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +01001001 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +00001002 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001003 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +02001004 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
1005 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001006
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001007 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1008 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1009
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001010- GPIO Support:
1011 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
1012 CONFIG_PCA953X_INFO - enable pca953x info command
1013
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +00001014 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
1015 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
1016 pins supported by a particular chip.
1017
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001018 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1019 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1020
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001021- Timestamp Support:
1022
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001023 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
1024 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
1025 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001026 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001027
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001028- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
1029 Zero or more of the following:
1030 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
1031 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
1032 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
1033 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
1034 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
1035 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
1036 disk/part_efi.c
1037 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001038
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01001039 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
1040 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001041 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001042
1043- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001044 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
1045 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001046
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001047 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
1048 be performed by calling the function
1049 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1050 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001051
1052- ATAPI Support:
1053 CONFIG_ATAPI
1054
1055 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1056
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001057- LBA48 Support
1058 CONFIG_LBA48
1059
1060 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001061 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001062 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1063 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1064
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001065 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001066 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1067 Default is 32bit.
1068
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001069- SCSI Support:
1070 At the moment only there is only support for the
1071 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1072 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1073
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001074 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1075 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1076 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001077 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1078 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001079 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001080
Stefan Reinauer447c0312012-10-29 05:23:48 +00001081 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
1082 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
1083
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001084- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001085 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001086 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1087
1088 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1089 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1090 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1091 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1092
1093 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1094 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1095 example with the "sspi" command.
1096
1097 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1098 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1099 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001100
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001101 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001102 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001103
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001104 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1105 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001106 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001107 write routine for first time initialisation.
1108
1109 CONFIG_TULIP
1110 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1111 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1112 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1113
1114 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1115 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1116
1117 CONFIG_NS8382X
1118 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1119
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001120- NETWORK Support (other):
1121
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001122 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1123 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1124
1125 CONFIG_RMII
1126 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1127
1128 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1129 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1130 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1131
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001132 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1133 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1134
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001135 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001136 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1137
1138 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1139 Define this to hold the physical address
1140 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1141
1142 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1143 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1144
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001145 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001146 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1147
1148 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1149 Define this to hold the physical address
1150 of the device (I/O space)
1151
1152 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1153 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1154
1155 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1156 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1157 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1158
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001159 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1160 Support for davinci emac
1161
1162 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1163 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1164
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001165 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1166 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1167
1168 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1169 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1170 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1171 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1172 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1173 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1174 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1175 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1176
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001177 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001178 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1179
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001180 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001181 Define this to hold the physical address
1182 of the device (I/O space)
1183
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001184 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001185 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1186
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001187 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001188 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1189 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001190 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001191
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001192 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1193 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1194
1195 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1196 Define the number of ports to be used
1197
1198 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1199 Define the ETH PHY's address
1200
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001201 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1202 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1203
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001204- TPM Support:
1205 CONFIG_GENERIC_LPC_TPM
1206 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1207 per system is supported at this time.
1208
1209 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1210 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1211 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1212 0xfed40000.
1213
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001214- USB Support:
1215 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001216 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001217 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1218 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001219 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001220 storage devices.
1221 Note:
1222 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1223 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001224 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1225 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1226 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001227 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1228 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001229 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1230 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1231 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001232 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1233 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001234 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001235 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1236 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001237
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001238 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1239 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1240
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001241- USB Device:
1242 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1243 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1244 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001245 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001246 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1247 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001248 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001249 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1250 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1251 a Linux host by
1252 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1253 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1254 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1255 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001256
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001257 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1258 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001259
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001260 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1261 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1262 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001263
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301264 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1265 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1266 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1267 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1268 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1269 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1270 speed.
1271
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001272 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001273 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1274 be set to usbtty.
1275
1276 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001277 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001278 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001279 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001280
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001281 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001282 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001283 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001284
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001285 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001286 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001287 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001288 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1289 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1290 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1291
1292 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1293 Define this string as the name of your company for
1294 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001295
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001296 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1297 Define this string as the name of your product
1298 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1299
1300 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1301 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1302 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1303 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1304 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001305
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001306 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1307 Define this as the unique Product ID
1308 for your device
1309 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001310
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001311- ULPI Layer Support:
1312 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1313 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1314 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1315 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1316 viewport is supported.
1317 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1318 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stach6d365ea2012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001319 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1320 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1321 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001322
1323- MMC Support:
1324 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1325 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1326 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1327 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001328 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1329 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001330
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001331 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1332 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1333
1334 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1335 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1336
1337 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1338 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1339
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001340- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1341 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1342 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1343 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1344
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001345 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1346 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001347 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1348
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001349 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001350 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1351 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1352
1353 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001354 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001355 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1356 have not defined a custom partition
1357
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001358- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1359 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001360
1361 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1362 file in FAT formatted partition.
1363
1364 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1365 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001366
Gabe Black84cd9322012-10-12 14:26:11 +00001367CBFS (Coreboot Filesystem) support
1368 CONFIG_CMD_CBFS
1369
1370 Define this to enable support for reading from a Coreboot
1371 filesystem. Available commands are cbfsinit, cbfsinfo, cbfsls
1372 and cbfsload.
1373
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001374- Keyboard Support:
1375 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1376
1377 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1378 support
1379
1380 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1381 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1382 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1383 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1384 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1385
1386- Video support:
1387 CONFIG_VIDEO
1388
1389 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1390 video).
1391
1392 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1393
1394 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1395
1396 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001397 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001398 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1399 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1400 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001401
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001402 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001403 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001404 are possible:
1405 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001406 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001407
1408 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1409 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1410 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1411 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1412 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1413 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1414 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001415 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1416
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001417 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001418 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001419
1420
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001421 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001422 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001423 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1424 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1425
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001426 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001427 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001428 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1429 support, and should also define these other macros:
1430
1431 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1432 CONFIG_VIDEO
1433 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1434 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1435 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1436 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1437 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1438 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1439
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001440 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1441 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1442 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1443 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001444
Simon Glass058d59b2012-12-03 13:59:47 +00001445 CONFIG_VIDEO_VGA
1446
1447 Enable the VGA video / BIOS for x86. The alternative if you
1448 are using coreboot is to use the coreboot frame buffer
1449 driver.
1450
1451
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001452- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001453 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001454
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001455 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1456 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1457 defined in your board-specific files.
1458 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001459
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001460- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1461
1462 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1463 display); also select one of the supported displays
1464 by defining one of these:
1465
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001466 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1467
1468 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1469
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001470 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001471
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001472 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001473
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001474 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001475
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001476 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1477 Active, color, single scan.
1478
1479 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1480
1481 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001482 Active, color, single scan.
1483
1484 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1485
1486 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1487 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1488
1489 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1490
1491 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1492 Active, color, single scan.
1493
1494 CONFIG_HLD1045
1495
1496 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1497 Active, color, single scan.
1498
1499 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1500
1501 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1502 or
1503 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1504 or
1505 Hitachi SP14Q002
1506
1507 320x240. Black & white.
1508
1509 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001510 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001511
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001512 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1513
1514 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (tyically 4KB). If this is
1515 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1516 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1517 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1518 a per-section basis.
1519
Simon Glass0d89efe2012-10-17 13:24:59 +00001520 CONFIG_CONSOLE_SCROLL_LINES
1521
1522 When the console need to be scrolled, this is the number of
1523 lines to scroll by. It defaults to 1. Increasing this makes
1524 the console jump but can help speed up operation when scrolling
1525 is slow.
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001526
Tom Wai-Hong Tam45d7f522012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001527 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1528
1529 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1530
Tom Wai-Hong Tam735987c2012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001531 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1532
1533 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1534 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1535
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001536- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001537
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001538 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1539 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1540 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001541 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001542 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1543 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1544 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1545 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001546
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001547 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1548
1549 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1550 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
1551 (see README.displaying-bmps and README.arm-unaligned-accesses).
1552 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1553 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1554 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1555 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1556 there is no need to set this option.
1557
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001558 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1559
1560 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1561 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1562 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1563 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1564 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1565 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1566
1567 Example:
1568 setenv splashpos m,m
1569 => image at center of screen
1570
1571 setenv splashpos 30,20
1572 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1573
1574 setenv splashpos -10,m
1575 => vertically centered image
1576 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1577
Nikita Kiryanov581bb412013-01-30 21:39:57 +00001578 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_PREPARE
1579
1580 If this option is set then the board_splash_screen_prepare()
1581 function, which must be defined in your code, is called as part
1582 of the splash screen display sequence. It gives the board an
1583 opportunity to prepare the splash image data before it is
1584 processed and sent to the frame buffer by U-Boot.
1585
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001586- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1587
1588 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1589 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1590 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1591
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001592- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1593
1594 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1595 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1596 bmp command.
1597
Lei Wenf2b96df2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00001598- Do compresssing for memory range:
1599 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
1600
1601 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
1602 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
1603
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001604- Compression support:
1605 CONFIG_BZIP2
1606
1607 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1608 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1609 compressed images are supported.
1610
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001611 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001612 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001613 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001614
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001615 CONFIG_LZMA
1616
1617 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1618 images is included.
1619
1620 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1621 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1622 formula:
1623
1624 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1625
1626 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1627 and Literal pos bits.
1628
1629 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1630 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1631 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1632 a very small buffer.
1633
1634 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1635 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001636 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001637
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001638- MII/PHY support:
1639 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1640
1641 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1642
1643 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1644
1645 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1646
1647 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1648
1649 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001650 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001651
1652 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1653
1654 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1655 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1656 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1657 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1658
1659 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1660
1661 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1662 command issued before MII status register can be read
1663
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001664- Ethernet address:
1665 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001666 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001667 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1668 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001669 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1670 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001671
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001672 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1673 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001674 is not determined automatically.
1675
1676- IP address:
1677 CONFIG_IPADDR
1678
1679 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001680 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001681 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001682 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001683
1684- Server IP address:
1685 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1686
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001687 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001688 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001689 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001690
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001691 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1692
1693 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1694 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1695
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001696- Gateway IP address:
1697 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
1698
1699 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
1700 default router where packets to other networks are
1701 sent to.
1702 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
1703
1704- Subnet mask:
1705 CONFIG_NETMASK
1706
1707 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
1708 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
1709 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
1710 forwarded through a router.
1711 (Environment variable "netmask")
1712
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001713- Multicast TFTP Mode:
1714 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
1715
1716 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
1717 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001718 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001719 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
1720 multicast group.
1721
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001722- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1723 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1724
1725 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1726 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1727 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1728 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1729 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1730 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1731 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1732 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001733 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001734
1735 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1736 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1737 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1738 4th and following
1739 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1740
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001741- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001742 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1743 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001744
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001745 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
1746 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
1747 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
1748 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
1749 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
1750 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
1751 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
1752 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
1753 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1754 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1755 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1756 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001757 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001758
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001759 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1760 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001761
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001762 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
1763 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
1764 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
1765 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
1766 is not available.
1767
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001768 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
1769 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
1770 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
1771 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
1772 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
1773 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
1774 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001775 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001776
1777 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1778 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1779 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001780 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001781 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1782 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001783
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001784 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1785
1786 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1787 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1788 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1789 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1790 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1791 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1792 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1793 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1794 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1795 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1796 this delay.
1797
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001798 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
1799 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
1800 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
1801 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
1802 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
1803
1804 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
1805
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001806 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001807 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001808
1809 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1810
1811 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1812
1813 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1814 of the device.
1815
1816 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1817
1818 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1819 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001820 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001821
1822 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1823
1824 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1825 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1826
1827 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
1828
1829 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
1830
1831 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
1832
1833 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
1834
1835 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
1836
1837 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
1838
1839 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
1840
1841 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
1842 device in .1 of milliwatts.
1843
1844 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
1845
1846 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
1847
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001848- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
1849
1850 Several configurations allow to display the current
1851 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
1852 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
1853 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
1854 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
1855 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
1856 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
1857 feature in U-Boot.
1858
1859- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
1860
1861 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
1862 on those systems that support this (optional)
1863 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
1864
1865- I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C | CONFIG_SOFT_I2C
1866
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001867 These enable I2C serial bus commands. Defining either of
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001868 (but not both of) CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C will
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001869 include the appropriate I2C driver for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001870
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001871 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001872 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001873 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
1874 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001875 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001876
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001877 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001878
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001879 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C configures u-boot to use a software (aka
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001880 bit-banging) driver instead of CPM or similar hardware
1881 support for I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001882
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001883 There are several other quantities that must also be
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001884 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001885
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001886 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001887 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001888 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001889 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001890
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001891 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02001892 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001893 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
1894 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
1895 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001896
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05001897 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
1898
1899 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1900 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1901 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
1902 commands until the slave device responds.
1903
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001904 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001905
1906 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SOFT_I2C)
1907 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
1908 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001909
1910 I2C_INIT
1911
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001912 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001913 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001914
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001915 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001916
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001917 I2C_PORT
1918
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001919 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
1920 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
1921 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001922
1923 I2C_ACTIVE
1924
1925 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
1926 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
1927 define can be null.
1928
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001929 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
1930
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001931 I2C_TRISTATE
1932
1933 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
1934 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
1935 define can be null.
1936
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001937 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
1938
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001939 I2C_READ
1940
1941 Code that returns TRUE if the I2C data line is high,
1942 FALSE if it is low.
1943
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001944 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
1945
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001946 I2C_SDA(bit)
1947
1948 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C data line high. If it
1949 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1950
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001951 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001952 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001953 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001954
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001955 I2C_SCL(bit)
1956
1957 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
1958 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1959
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001960 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001961 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001962 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001963
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001964 I2C_DELAY
1965
1966 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
1967 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001968 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001969 like:
1970
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001971 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001972
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04001973 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
1974
1975 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
1976 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
1977 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
1978 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
1979
1980 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
1981 the generic GPIO functions.
1982
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001983 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001984
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001985 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1986 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1987 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
1988 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
1989 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
1990 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
1991 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
1992 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001993
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04001994 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
1995
1996 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
1997 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
1998 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
1999 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
2000 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
2001 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
2002 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
2003 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
2004
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002005 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
2006
2007 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
2008 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
2009 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
2010
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002011 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
2012
2013 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002014 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
2015 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002016 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
2017
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002018 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002019
2020 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002021 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05002022 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
2023 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002024
2025 e.g.
2026 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002027 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002028
2029 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
2030
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002031 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002032 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002033
2034 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
2035
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002036 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002037
2038 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
2039 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
2040
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002041 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002042
2043 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
2044 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
2045
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002046 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002047
2048 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
2049 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
2050
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002051 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07002052
2053 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
2054 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
2055 specified DTT device.
2056
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002057 CONFIG_FSL_I2C
2058
2059 Define this option if you want to use Freescale's I2C driver in
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01002060 drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c.
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002061
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002062 CONFIG_I2C_MUX
2063
2064 Define this option if you have I2C devices reached over 1 .. n
2065 I2C Muxes like the pca9544a. This option addes a new I2C
2066 Command "i2c bus [muxtype:muxaddr:muxchannel]" which adds a
2067 new I2C Bus to the existing I2C Busses. If you select the
2068 new Bus with "i2c dev", u-bbot sends first the commandos for
2069 the muxes to activate this new "bus".
2070
2071 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS must be also defined, to use this
2072 feature!
2073
2074 Example:
2075 Adding a new I2C Bus reached over 2 pca9544a muxes
2076 The First mux with address 70 and channel 6
2077 The Second mux with address 71 and channel 4
2078
2079 => i2c bus pca9544a:70:6:pca9544a:71:4
2080
2081 Use the "i2c bus" command without parameter, to get a list
2082 of I2C Busses with muxes:
2083
2084 => i2c bus
2085 Busses reached over muxes:
2086 Bus ID: 2
2087 reached over Mux(es):
2088 pca9544a@70 ch: 4
2089 Bus ID: 3
2090 reached over Mux(es):
2091 pca9544a@70 ch: 6
2092 pca9544a@71 ch: 4
2093 =>
2094
2095 If you now switch to the new I2C Bus 3 with "i2c dev 3"
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00002096 u-boot first sends the command to the mux@70 to enable
2097 channel 6, and then the command to the mux@71 to enable
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002098 the channel 4.
2099
2100 After that, you can use the "normal" i2c commands as
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00002101 usual to communicate with your I2C devices behind
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002102 the 2 muxes.
2103
2104 This option is actually implemented for the bitbanging
2105 algorithm in common/soft_i2c.c and for the Hardware I2C
2106 Bus on the MPC8260. But it should be not so difficult
2107 to add this option to other architectures.
2108
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06002109 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
2110
2111 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2112 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2113 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2114 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2115 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2116 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2117 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002118
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002119- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2120
2121 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2122 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2123 D/As on the SACSng board)
2124
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002125 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2126
2127 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2128 only SH7757 is supported.
2129
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002130 CONFIG_SPI_X
2131
2132 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2133 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2134
2135 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2136
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002137 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2138 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2139 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2140 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2141 defined, the board configuration must define several
2142 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2143 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002144
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002145 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2146
2147 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2148 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2149 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002150 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002151 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2152
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002153 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2154
2155 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002156 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002157
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002158- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2159
2160 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2161
2162 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2163
2164 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2165 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2166
2167 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2168
2169 Enables support for FPGA family.
2170 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2171
2172 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002173
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002174 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002175
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002176 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002177
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002178 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002179
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002180 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002181
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002182 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2183 status by the configuration function. This option
2184 will require a board or device specific function to
2185 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002186
2187 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2188
2189 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2190 configuration driver.
2191
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002192 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002193 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2194
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002195 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002196
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002197 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2198 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2199 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2200 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002201
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002202 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002203
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002204 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
2205 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
2206 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002207 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002208
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002209 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002210
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002211 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002212 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002213
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002214 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002215
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002216 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002217 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002218
2219- Configuration Management:
2220 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2221
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002222 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2223 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002224
2225- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2226
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002227 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2228 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002229 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002230 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2231 protects these variables from casual modification by
2232 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2233 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002234 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002235
2236 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2237 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002238 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002239 these parameters.
2240
2241 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2242 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002243 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002244 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2245 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2246 read-only.]
2247
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002248 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2249 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2250 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2251 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2252
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002253- Protected RAM:
2254 CONFIG_PRAM
2255
2256 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2257 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2258 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2259 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2260 this default value by defining an environment
2261 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2262 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2263 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2264 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2265 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2266 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2267 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2268
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002269 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002270 saveenv
2271
2272 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2273 either, which results in a memory region that will
2274 not be affected by reboots.
2275
2276 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2277 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2278 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2279 following board configurations are known to be
2280 "pRAM-clean":
2281
Wolfgang Denk1b0757e2012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002282 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2283 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002284 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002285
Gabe Black40fef042012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002286- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2287 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2288 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2289 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2290 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2291 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2292 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2293
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002294- Error Recovery:
2295 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2296
2297 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2298 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2299 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002300 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002301 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2302 useful during development since you can try to debug
2303 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2304
2305 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2306
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002307 This variable defines the number of retries for
2308 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2309 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2310 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002311
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002312 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2313
2314 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2315
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002316 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2317
2318 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2319 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2320 try longer timeout such as
2321 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2322
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002323- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002324 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002325
2326 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2327
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01002328 Note that this feature has NOT been implemented yet
2329 for the "hush" shell.
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002330
2331
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002332 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002333
2334 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2335 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2336 powerful command line syntax like
2337 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2338 constructs ("shell scripts").
2339
2340 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2341 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2342
2343
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002344 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002345
2346 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2347 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2348 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2349
2350 Note:
2351
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002352 In the current implementation, the local variables
2353 space and global environment variables space are
2354 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2355 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2356 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2357 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2358 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002359
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002360 Global environment variables are those you use
2361 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2362 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2363 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002364
2365 To store commands and special characters in a
2366 variable, please use double quotation marks
2367 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2368 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2369 symbols.
2370
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002371- Commandline Editing and History:
2372 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2373
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002374 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkb9365a22006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002375 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002376
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002377- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002378 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2379
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002380 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2381 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002382 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002383
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002384 For example, place something like this in your
2385 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002386
2387 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2388 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2389 "myvar2=value2\0"
2390
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002391 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2392 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2393 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2394 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002395 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002396 You better know what you are doing here.
2397
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002398 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2399 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002400 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002401 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002402
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002403 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2404
2405 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2406 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2407 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2408
2409 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2410
2411 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2412 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2413 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2414 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2415 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2416
Tom Rini7e27f892012-10-24 07:28:16 +00002417 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
2418
2419 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
2420 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
2421 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
2422
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002423 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2424
2425 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
2426 intialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
2427 that so that the environment is not available until
2428 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
2429 this is instead controlled by the value of
2430 /config/load-environment.
2431
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002432- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002433 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2434
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002435 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2436 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2437 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002438
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002439- Serial Flash support
2440 CONFIG_CMD_SF
2441
2442 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
2443 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
2444
2445 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
2446 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2447 commands.
2448
2449 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2450 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2451 flash is present on the system.
2452
2453 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2454 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2455 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2456 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2457
Simon Glass24007272012-10-08 13:16:02 +00002458 CONFIG_CMD_SF_TEST
2459
2460 Define this option to include a destructive SPI flash
2461 test ('sf test').
2462
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002463- SystemACE Support:
2464 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2465
2466 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2467 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002468 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002469 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002470
2471 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002472 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002473
2474 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2475 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2476
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002477- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2478 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2479
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002480 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002481 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002482 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002483 number generator is used.
2484
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002485 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2486 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2487 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2488
2489 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002490 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2491 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2492 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2493 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2494 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2495 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2496
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00002497- Hashing support:
2498 CONFIG_CMD_HASH
2499
2500 This enables a generic 'hash' command which can produce
2501 hashes / digests from a few algorithms (e.g. SHA1, SHA256).
2502
2503 CONFIG_HASH_VERIFY
2504
2505 Enable the hash verify command (hash -v). This adds to code
2506 size a little.
2507
2508 CONFIG_SHA1 - support SHA1 hashing
2509 CONFIG_SHA256 - support SHA256 hashing
2510
2511 Note: There is also a sha1sum command, which should perhaps
2512 be deprecated in favour of 'hash sha1'.
2513
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002514- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002515 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2516
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002517 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2518 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2519 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2520 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2521 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2522 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002523
Simon Glass3a608ca2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00002524- Detailed boot stage timing
2525 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
2526 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
2527 of the boot process.
2528
2529 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
2530 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
2531 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
2532 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
2533 the limit, recording will stop.
2534
2535 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
2536 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
2537
2538 Timer summary in microseconds:
2539 Mark Elapsed Stage
2540 0 0 reset
2541 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
2542 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
2543 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
2544 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
2545 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
2546 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
2547 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
2548
Simon Glass2eba38c2012-09-28 08:56:39 +00002549 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTSTAGE
2550 Add a 'bootstage' command which supports printing a report
2551 and un/stashing of bootstage data.
2552
Simon Glass94fd1312012-09-28 08:56:37 +00002553 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_FDT
2554 Stash the bootstage information in the FDT. A root 'bootstage'
2555 node is created with each bootstage id as a child. Each child
2556 has a 'name' property and either 'mark' containing the
2557 mark time in microsecond, or 'accum' containing the
2558 accumulated time for that bootstage id in microseconds.
2559 For example:
2560
2561 bootstage {
2562 154 {
2563 name = "board_init_f";
2564 mark = <3575678>;
2565 };
2566 170 {
2567 name = "lcd";
2568 accum = <33482>;
2569 };
2570 };
2571
2572 Code in the Linux kernel can find this in /proc/devicetree.
2573
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002574Legacy uImage format:
2575
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002576 Arg Where When
2577 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002578 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002579 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002580 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002581 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002582 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002583 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2584 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2585 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002586 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002587 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2588 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2589 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2590 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002591 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002592 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002593
2594 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2595 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2596 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2597 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2598 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2599 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2600 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002601 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002602 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2603 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2604
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002605 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002606
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002607 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd52004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002608 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2609 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002610
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002611 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2612 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2613 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2614 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2615 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2616 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2617 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2618 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2619 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2620 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2621 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2622 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2623 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2624 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2625 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2626 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2627 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2628 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2629 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2630 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2631 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2632 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2633 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2634 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2635 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2636 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2637 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2638 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2639 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2640 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2641 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2642 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2643 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2644 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2645 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2646 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2647 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2648 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2649 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2650 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2651 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2652 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2653 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2654 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2655 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2656 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2657 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002658
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002659 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002660
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002661 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002662 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
2663 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00002664
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002665 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
2666 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002667 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002668 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
2669 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
2670 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002671 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
2672 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002673 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002674
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002675FIT uImage format:
2676
2677 Arg Where When
2678 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
2679 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
2680 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
2681 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
2682 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
2683 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01002684 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002685 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
2686 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
2687 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
2688 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
2689 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002690 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
2691 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002692 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
2693 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
2694 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
2695 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
2696 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
2697 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
2698 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
2699 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
2700
2701 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2702 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
2703 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002704 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002705 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
2706 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
2707 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
2708 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
2709 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
2710 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
2711 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
2712 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
2713 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
2714 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
2715 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
2716 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
2717
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002718 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002719 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
2720
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002721 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002722 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
2723
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002724 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002725 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
2726
Gabe Blackd95f6ec2012-10-25 16:31:10 +00002727- FIT image support:
2728 CONFIG_FIT
2729 Enable support for the FIT uImage format.
2730
2731 CONFIG_FIT_BEST_MATCH
2732 When no configuration is explicitly selected, default to the
2733 one whose fdt's compatibility field best matches that of
2734 U-Boot itself. A match is considered "best" if it matches the
2735 most specific compatibility entry of U-Boot's fdt's root node.
2736 The order of entries in the configuration's fdt is ignored.
2737
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002738- Standalone program support:
2739 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
2740
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002741 This option defines a board specific value for the
2742 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
2743 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002744 settings.
2745
2746- Frame Buffer Address:
2747 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
2748
2749 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denk44a53b52013-01-03 00:43:59 +00002750 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
2751 when using a graphics controller has separate video
2752 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
2753 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
2754 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
2755 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
2756 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002757
2758 Please see board_init_f function.
2759
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01002760- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
2761 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
2762 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
2763 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
2764
2765 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
2766 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
2767
2768- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
2769 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
2770
2771 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
2772 Needed for mtdparts command support.
2773
2774 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
2775
2776 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
2777 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
2778
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002779- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002780 CONFIG_SPL
2781 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002782
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002783 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
2784 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
2785
2786 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
2787 Maximum binary size (text, data and rodata) of the SPL binary.
2788
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002789 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
2790 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002791
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002792 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
2793 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
2794 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
2795
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002796 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
2797 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
2798
2799 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
2800 Maximum binary size of the BSS section of the SPL binary.
2801
2802 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
2803 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
2804
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002805 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
2806 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
2807 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
2808 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
2809
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002810 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
2811 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
2812
2813 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
2814 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002815
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07002816 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
2817 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
2818 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
2819 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
2820
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07002821 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
2822 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
2823 about the running system.
2824
Scott Wood4b919722012-09-20 16:35:21 -05002825 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
2826 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
2827
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002828 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
2829 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002830
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002831 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
2832 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002833
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002834 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
2835 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002836
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002837 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
2838 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002839
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002840 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
2841 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002842
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002843 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
2844 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
2845 CONFIG_SYS_MMC_SD_FAT_BOOT_PARTITION
2846 Address, size and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
2847 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
2848
2849 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
2850 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
2851
2852 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
2853 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from FAT
2854
Scott Wood06f60ae2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00002855 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
2856 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
2857 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
2858 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
2859 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
2860
Scott Wood6f2f01b2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05002861 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
2862 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
2863 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
2864
2865 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
2866 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
2867
2868 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
2869 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
2870
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002871 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002872 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
2873 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002874
2875 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
2876 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
2877 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
2878 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
2879 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
2880 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002881 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002882
2883 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002884 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
2885
2886 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
2887 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
2888
2889 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
2890 Size of image to load
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002891
2892 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002893 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002894
2895 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
2896 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
2897 data. This is used for example on davinci plattforms.
2898
2899 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
2900 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
2901 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
2902
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002903 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
2904 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002905
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002906 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
2907 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002908
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002909 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
2910 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002911
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02002912 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
2913 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
2914
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002915 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
2916 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002917
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00002918 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
2919 Linker address to which the SPL should be padded before
2920 appending the SPL payload.
2921
Scott Woodca2fca22012-09-21 16:27:32 -05002922 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
2923 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
2924 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
2925 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
2926
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002927Modem Support:
2928--------------
2929
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02002930[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002931
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002932- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002933 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
2934
2935- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
2936 CONFIG_HWFLOW
2937
2938- Modem debug support:
2939 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
2940
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002941 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
2942 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002943
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002944- Interrupt support (PPC):
2945
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002946 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
2947 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002948 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002949 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002950 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002951 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002952 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002953 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
2954 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
2955 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002956
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002957- General:
2958
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002959 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
2960 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
2961 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002962 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002963 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
2964 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
2965 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002966
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002967 If there are no modem init strings in the
2968 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
2969 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002970 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002971
2972 See also: doc/README.Modem
2973
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00002974Board initialization settings:
2975------------------------------
2976
2977During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
2978to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
2979before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
2980following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
2981architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
2982typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
2983
2984- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
2985- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
2986- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
2987- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002988
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002989Configuration Settings:
2990-----------------------
2991
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002992- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002993 undefine this when you're short of memory.
2994
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06002995- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
2996 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
2997
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002998- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002999 prompt for user input.
3000
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003001- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003002
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003003- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003004
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003005- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003006
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003007- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003008 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
3009 booted
3010
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003011- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003012 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
3013
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003014- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003015 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003016
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003017- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003018 If the board specific function
3019 extern int overwrite_console (void);
3020 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003021 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
3022
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003023- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003024 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003025
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003026- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003027 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
3028
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003029- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003030 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
3031 simple memory test.
3032
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003033- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003034 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003035
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003036- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00003037 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
3038 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
3039
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003040- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
3041 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003042 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003043 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003044 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
3045 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
3046 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003047 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003048 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003049 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003050
3051 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
3052 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
3053 be touched.
3054
3055 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
3056 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
3057 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
3058 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
3059 problems.
3060
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003061- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003062 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
3063
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003064- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003065 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
3066
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003067- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003068 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
3069 Cogent motherboard)
3070
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003071- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003072 Physical start address of Flash memory.
3073
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003074- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003075 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
3076 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02003077 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003078 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003079
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003080- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003081 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
3082 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
3083 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
3084 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003085
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003086- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003087 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
3088
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003089- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003090 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
3091 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003092 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003093 to adjust this setting to your needs.
3094
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003095- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003096 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
3097 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003098 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
3099 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
3100 enviroment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
3101 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003102 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003103 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
3104 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
3105 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003106
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06003107- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
3108 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
3109 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
3110 is enabled.
3111
3112- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
3113 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
3114 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3115
3116- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
3117 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
3118 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3119
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003120- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003121 Max number of Flash memory banks
3122
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003123- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003124 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
3125
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003126- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003127 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
3128
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003129- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003130 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
3131
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003132- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003133 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
3134
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003135- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003136 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
3137
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003138- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003139 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
3140 instead of U-Boot software protection.
3141
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003142- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003143
3144 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
3145 without this option such a download has to be
3146 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
3147 copy from RAM to flash.
3148
3149 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
3150 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003151 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
3152 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003153 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
3154
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003155- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003156 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003157 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
3158
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02003159- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003160 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
3161 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003162
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01003163- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
3164 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
3165 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
3166 to the MTD layer.
3167
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003168- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02003169 Use buffered writes to flash.
3170
3171- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
3172 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
3173 write commands.
3174
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003175- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01003176 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
3177 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
3178 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
3179 optionally available.
3180
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05003181- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
3182 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
3183 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
3184 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
3185
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003186- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003187 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
3188 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003189 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
3190 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003191 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003192 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
3193
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003194- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
3195
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02003196 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
3197 internally to store the environment settings. The default
3198 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
3199 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
3200 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003201
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003202- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3203- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
3204 Enable validation of the values given to enviroment variables when
3205 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
3206 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
3207 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
3208
3209 The format of the list is:
3210 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003211 access_atribute = [a|r|o|c]
3212 attributes = type_attribute[access_atribute]
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003213 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
3214 list = entry[,list]
3215
3216 The type attributes are:
3217 s - String (default)
3218 d - Decimal
3219 x - Hexadecimal
3220 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
3221 i - IP address
3222 m - MAC address
3223
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003224 The access attributes are:
3225 a - Any (default)
3226 r - Read-only
3227 o - Write-once
3228 c - Change-default
3229
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003230 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3231 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
3232 envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
3233
3234 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
3235 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
3236 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
3237 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
3238 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
3239 ".flags" variable.
3240
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003241- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
3242 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
3243 access flags.
3244
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00003245- CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_BOARD
3246 This selects the architecture-generic board system instead of the
3247 architecture-specific board files. It is intended to move boards
3248 to this new framework over time. Defining this will disable the
3249 arch/foo/lib/board.c file and use common/board_f.c and
3250 common/board_r.c instead. To use this option your architecture
3251 must support it (i.e. must define __HAVE_ARCH_GENERIC_BOARD in
3252 its config.mk file). If you find problems enabling this option on
3253 your board please report the problem and send patches!
3254
Simon Glass632efa72013-03-11 07:06:48 +00003255- CONFIG_SYS_SYM_OFFSETS
3256 This is set by architectures that use offsets for link symbols
3257 instead of absolute values. So bss_start is obtained using an
3258 offset _bss_start_ofs from CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE, rather than
3259 directly. You should not need to touch this setting.
3260
3261
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003262The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
3263of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
3264following configurations:
3265
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00003266- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
3267
3268 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
3269 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
3270
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003271- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003272
3273 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
3274
3275 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
3276 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
3277 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
3278 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
3279 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
3280 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
3281 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
3282 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
3283 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
3284 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
3285 between U-Boot and the environment.
3286
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003287 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003288
3289 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
3290 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
3291 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
3292 for this sector is given here.
3293
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003294 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003295
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003296 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003297
3298 This is just another way to specify the start address of
3299 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003300 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003301
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003302 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003303
3304 Size of the sector containing the environment.
3305
3306
3307 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
3308 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
3309 the environment.
3310
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003311 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003312
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003313 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003314 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003315 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
3316 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
3317
3318 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
3319 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
3320 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
3321 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
3322 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
3323 updating the environment in flash makes it always
3324 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
3325 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
3326 RAM, your target system will be dead.
3327
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003328 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
3329 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003330
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003331 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003332 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00003333 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003334 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003335
3336BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
3337source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
3338accordingly!
3339
3340
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02003341- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003342
3343 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
3344 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
3345 environment.
3346
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003347 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3348 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003349
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003350 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003351 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
3352 can just be read and written to, without any special
3353 provision.
3354
3355BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
3356in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003357console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003358U-Boot will hang.
3359
3360Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
3361environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
3362keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
3363to save the current settings.
3364
3365
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02003366- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003367
3368 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
3369 device and a driver for it.
3370
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003371 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3372 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003373
3374 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
3375 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
3376
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003377 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003378 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
3379 The default address is zero.
3380
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003381 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003382 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
3383 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
3384 would require six bits.
3385
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003386 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003387 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003388 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003389
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003390 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003391 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
3392 that this is NOT the chip address length!
3393
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003394 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003395 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
3396 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
3397 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
3398 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
3399 byte chips.
3400
3401 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
3402 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
3403 in the chip address.
3404
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003405 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003406 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
3407
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003408 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
3409 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
3410 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
3411
3412 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
3413 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
3414 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
3415 EEPROM. For example:
3416
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +02003417 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS "pca9547:70:d\0"
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003418
3419 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
3420 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003421
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003422- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003423
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003424 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003425 want to use for the environment.
3426
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003427 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3428 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3429 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003430
3431 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
3432 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
3433 at the specified address.
3434
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003435- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
3436
3437 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
3438 want to use for the local device's environment.
3439
3440 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3441 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
3442
3443 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
3444 environment area within the remote memory space. The
3445 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003446 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003447
3448BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
3449"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003450environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
3451but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003452
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003453- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003454
3455 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
3456 for the environment.
3457
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003458 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3459 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003460
3461 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003462 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
3463 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003464
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003465 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003466
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003467 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003468 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
3469 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003470 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003471 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003472
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003473 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
3474
3475 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
3476 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
3477 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
3478 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
3479 the range to be avoided.
3480
3481 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
3482
3483 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
3484 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
3485 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
3486 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
3487 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003488
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02003489- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
3490
3491 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
3492 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
3493 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
3494
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003495- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003496
3497 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
3498 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
3499 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
3500 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
3501 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
3502 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
3503 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
3504
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07003505Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003506has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02003507created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003508until then to read environment variables.
3509
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003510The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
3511is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
3512with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
3513necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
3514"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
3515have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003516
3517Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
3518the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003519use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003520
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003521- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003522 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003523
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003524 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003525 also needs to be defined.
3526
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003527- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003528 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003529
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08003530- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
3531 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
3532 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
3533 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
3534 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
3535 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
3536
Simon Glassb2b92f52012-11-30 13:01:18 +00003537- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
3538 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
3539 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
3540 to do this.
3541
Simon Glasse2e3e2b2012-11-30 13:01:19 +00003542- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
3543 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
3544 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
3545 present.
3546
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003547Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00003548---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003549
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003550- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003551 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
3552
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003553- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003554 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00003555
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003556 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
3557 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
3558 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003559
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003560- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
3561 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
3562 PowerPC SOCs.
3563
3564- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
3565 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
3566 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
3567
3568 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
3569 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
3570
3571- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
3572 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
3573 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003574 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003575 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
3576 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
3577 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
3578
3579 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
3580 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
3581
3582- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003583 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
3584 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003585 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3586 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3587
3588- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
3589 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
3590 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3591 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3592
3593- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
3594 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
3595 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
3596
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003597- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003598 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003599
3600 the default drive number (default value 0)
3601
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003602 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003603
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003604 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003605 (default value 1)
3606
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003607 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003608
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003609 defines the offset of register from address. It
3610 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003611 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003612
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003613 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
3614 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003615 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003616
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003617 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003618 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
3619 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
3620 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
3621 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003622
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003623- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
3624 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
3625 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
3626 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
3627 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
3628 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
3629 is requierd.
3630
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003631- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003632 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00003633 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003634
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003635- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003636
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00003637 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003638 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
3639 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
3640 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
3641 will become available only after programming the
3642 memory controller and running certain initialization
3643 sequences.
3644
3645 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
3646 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
3647 - MPC824X: data cache
3648 - PPC4xx: data cache
3649
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003650- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003651
3652 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003653 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
3654 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003655 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02003656 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003657 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
3658 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
3659 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003660
3661 Note:
3662 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
3663 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003664 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003665 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
3666 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
3667
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003668- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003669
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003670- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003671
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003672- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003673
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003674- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003675
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003676- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003677
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003678- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003679
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003680- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003681 SDRAM timing
3682
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003683- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003684 periodic timer for refresh
3685
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003686- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003687
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003688- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
3689 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
3690 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
3691 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003692 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
3693
3694- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003695 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
3696 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003697 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
3698
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003699- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
3700 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003701 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
3702 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
3703
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003704- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003705 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3706 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
3707
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003708- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01003709 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3710 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
3711
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003712- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003713 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3714 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
3715
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003716- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003717 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
3718 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
3719 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
3720
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003721- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003722 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
3723 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
3724 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
3725 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00003726
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003727- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3728 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
3729 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
3730 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3731 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
3732 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
3733 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
3734 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003735 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00003736
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01003737- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
3738 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
3739 required.
3740
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003741- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
3742 Only scan through and get the devices on the busses.
3743 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
3744 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
3745 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
3746 by coreboot or similar.
3747
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003748- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
3749 Chip has SRIO or not
3750
3751- CONFIG_SRIO1:
3752 Board has SRIO 1 port available
3753
3754- CONFIG_SRIO2:
3755 Board has SRIO 2 port available
3756
3757- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
3758 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3759
3760- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
3761 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3762
3763- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
3764 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3765
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04003766- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_16
3767 Defined to tell the NDFC that the NAND chip is using a
3768 16 bit bus.
3769
3770- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
3771 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
3772 a default value will be used.
3773
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003774- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003775 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
3776 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
3777
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003778 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
3779 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
3780
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003781- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003782 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
3783 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
3784 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003785
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08003786- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
3787 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
3788 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
3789 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
3790 header files or board specific files.
3791
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07003792- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
3793 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
3794
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003795- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003796 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
3797 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06003798
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003799- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
3800 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
3801
3802- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
3803 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00003804 to the given FEC; i. e.
3805 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003806 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
3807
3808 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
3809
3810- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
3811 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
3812 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
3813
3814- CONFIG_RMII
3815 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
3816 Note that this is a global option, we can't
3817 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
3818
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003819- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
3820 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
3821 The syntax is:
3822
3823 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
3824
3825 Where address/count indicate a memory area
3826 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
3827 area should have.
3828
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003829- CONFIG_LOOPW
3830 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003831 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003832
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003833- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
3834 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
3835 "md/mw" commands.
3836 Examples:
3837
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003838 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003839 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
3840
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003841 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003842 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
3843
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003844 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003845 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003846
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003847- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00003848 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003849 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
3850 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
3851 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003852
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003853 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
3854 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
3855 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
3856 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003857
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00003858- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02003859 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3860 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
3861 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00003862
Simon Glass4213fc22013-02-24 17:33:14 +00003863- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
3864 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
3865 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
3866 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
3867 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
3868 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
3869 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
3870 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
3871
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00003872- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
3873 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
3874 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
3875 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
3876 conditions but may increase the binary size.
3877
Simon Glass588a13f2013-02-14 04:18:54 +00003878- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
3879 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
3880 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Blackb16f5212012-11-27 21:08:06 +00003881
Mark Jacksonfc337052013-03-04 01:27:20 +00003882- CONFIG_SYS_MPUCLK
3883 Defines the MPU clock speed (in MHz).
3884
3885 NOTE : currently only supported on AM335x platforms.
Gabe Black5b5ece92012-11-29 16:23:41 +00003886
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003887Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
3888-----------------------------------
3889
3890The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
3891loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
3892This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3893are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3894within that device.
3895
3896- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_ADDR
3897 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
3898 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3899 is also specified.
3900
3901- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
3902 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
3903 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
3904 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
3905 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
3906
3907- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
3908 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
3909 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
3910 virtual address in NOR flash.
3911
3912- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
3913 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
3914 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
3915
3916- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
3917 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
3918 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3919
3920- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
3921 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
3922 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3923
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00003924- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
3925 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
3926 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003927 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
3928 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
3929 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003930
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003931Building the Software:
3932======================
3933
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003934Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
3935and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
3936all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
3937(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
3938recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
3939which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003940
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003941If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
3942have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
3943you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
3944Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
3945necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003946
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003947 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
3948 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003949
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05003950Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
3951 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
3952 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
3953 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
3954
3955 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
3956
3957 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
3958 be executed on computers running Windows.
3959
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003960U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
3961sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003962is done by typing:
3963
3964 make NAME_config
3965
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003966where "NAME_config" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003967rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00003968
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003969Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
3970 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
3971 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
3972 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003973 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003974
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003975 make TQM823L_config
3976 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003977
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003978 make TQM823L_LCD_config
3979 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003980
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003981 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003982
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003983
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003984Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
3985images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003986
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003987- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
3988- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
3989- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003990
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003991By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
3992in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
3993this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
3994
39951. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
3996
3997 make O=/tmp/build distclean
3998 make O=/tmp/build NAME_config
3999 make O=/tmp/build all
4000
40012. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
4002
4003 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
4004 make distclean
4005 make NAME_config
4006 make all
4007
4008Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
4009variable.
4010
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004011
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004012Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
4013for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
4014native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004015
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004016
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004017If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
4018to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
4019steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004020
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000040211. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00004022 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
4023 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000040242. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
4025 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
4026 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
40273. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
4028 your board
40293. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
4030 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
40314. Run "make <board>_config" with your new name.
40325. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
4033 to be installed on your target system.
40346. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
4035 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004036
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004037
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004038Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
4039==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004040
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004041If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
4042or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004043provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
4044the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004045official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004046
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004047But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
4048cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004049the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
4050just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004051for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
4052select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
4053environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
4054you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004055
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004056 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004057
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004058or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004059
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004060 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004061
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004062When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
4063U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
4064setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
4065built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
4066<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
4067location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
4068variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004069
4070 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
4071 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
4072 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
4073
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004074With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
4075log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
4076during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004077
4078
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004079See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004080
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004081
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004082Monitor Commands - Overview:
4083============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004084
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004085go - start application at address 'addr'
4086run - run commands in an environment variable
4087bootm - boot application image from memory
4088bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004089bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004090tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
4091 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
4092 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00004093tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004094rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
4095diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
4096loads - load S-Record file over serial line
4097loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
4098md - memory display
4099mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
4100nm - memory modify (constant address)
4101mw - memory write (fill)
4102cp - memory copy
4103cmp - memory compare
4104crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05004105i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004106sspi - SPI utility commands
4107base - print or set address offset
4108printenv- print environment variables
4109setenv - set environment variables
4110saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
4111protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
4112erase - erase FLASH memory
4113flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc10635af2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00004114nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004115bdinfo - print Board Info structure
4116iminfo - print header information for application image
4117coninfo - print console devices and informations
4118ide - IDE sub-system
4119loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004120loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004121mtest - simple RAM test
4122icache - enable or disable instruction cache
4123dcache - enable or disable data cache
4124reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
4125echo - echo args to console
4126version - print monitor version
4127help - print online help
4128? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004129
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004130
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004131Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
4132========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004133
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004134TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004135
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004136For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004137
4138
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004139Environment Variables:
4140======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004141
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004142U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
4143can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004144
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004145Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
4146"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
4147without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
4148environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
4149working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
4150environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004151
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004152Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
4153
4154List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004155
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004156 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004157
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004158 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004159
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004160 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004161
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004162 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004163
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004164 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004165
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004166 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
4167 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
4168 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
4169 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
4170 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
4171 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004172 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
4173 bootm_mapsize.
4174
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004175 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004176 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
4177 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
4178 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
4179 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
4180 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
4181 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004182
4183 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
4184 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
4185 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
4186 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
4187 environment variable.
4188
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02004189 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
4190 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
4191 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
4192
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004193 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
4194 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
4195 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
4196 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004197
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004198 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
4199 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
4200 be automatically started (by internally calling
4201 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004202
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004203 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
4204 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
4205 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
4206 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
4207 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004208
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04004209 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
4210 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00004211 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
4212 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
4213 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
4214 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
4215 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
4216 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
4217 access it during the boot procedure.
4218
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04004219 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
4220 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
4221 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
4222 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
4223 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
4224 must be accessible by the kernel.
4225
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00004226 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
4227 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
4228 defined.
4229
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00004230 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
4231 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
4232 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
4233 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
4234 it must be saved and board must be reset.
4235
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004236 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
4237 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
4238 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
4239 is usually what you want since it allows for
4240 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
4241 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004242 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004243 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
4244 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
4245 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
4246 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004247
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004248 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
4249 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
4250 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
4251 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
4252 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
4253 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004254
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004255 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004256
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004257 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
4258 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
4259 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
4260 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
4261 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
4262 boot time on your system, but requires that this
4263 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00004264
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004265 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004266
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004267 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
4268 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004269
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004270 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004271
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004272 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00004273
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004274 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004275
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004276 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004277
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004278 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004279
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00004280 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004281
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00004282 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
4283 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004284
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02004285 => setenv ethact FEC
4286 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
4287 => setenv ethact SCC
4288 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004289
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01004290 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
4291 available network interfaces.
4292 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
4293
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004294 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004295 either succeed or fail without retrying.
4296 When set to "once" the network operation will
4297 fail when all the available network interfaces
4298 are tried once without success.
4299 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
4300 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004301
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01004302 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01004303
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004304 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02004305 UDP source port.
4306
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004307 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
4308 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
4309
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004310 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
4311 we use the TFTP server's default block size
4312
4313 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
4314 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
4315 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
4316 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
4317 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
4318 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
4319 with unreliable TFTP servers.
4320
4321 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004322 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004323 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004324
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004325The following image location variables contain the location of images
4326used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
4327not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
4328variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
4329server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
4330loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
4331flash or offset in NAND flash.
4332
4333*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
4334boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
4335boards use these variables for other purposes.
4336
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004337Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
4338----- --------- ----------- --------------
4339u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
4340Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
4341device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
4342ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004343
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004344The following environment variables may be used and automatically
4345updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
4346depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004347
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004348 bootfile - see above
4349 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
4350 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
4351 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
4352 hostname - Target hostname
4353 ipaddr - see above
4354 netmask - Subnet Mask
4355 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
4356 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004357
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004358
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004359There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004360
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004361 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
4362 as type string and/or serial number
4363 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004364
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004365These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
4366the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
4367once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004368
4369
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004370Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004371
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004372 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
4373 with the "version" command. This variable is
4374 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004375
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004376
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004377Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
4378only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004379
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004380
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06004381Callback functions for environment variables:
4382---------------------------------------------
4383
4384For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
4385when their values are changed. This functionailty allows functions to
4386be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
4387deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
4388effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
4389
4390The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
4391U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
4392
4393These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
4394static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
4395in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
4396associations. The list must be in the following format:
4397
4398 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
4399 list = entry[,list]
4400
4401If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
4402Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
4403
4404Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
4405with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
4406override any association in the static list. You can define
4407CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
4408".callbacks" envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
4409
4410
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004411Command Line Parsing:
4412=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004413
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004414There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
4415the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004416
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004417Old, simple command line parser:
4418--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004419
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004420- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
4421- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004422- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004423- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
4424 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004425 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004426- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
4427 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004428
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004429Hush shell:
4430-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004431
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004432- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
4433 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
4434 until...do...done, ...
4435- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
4436 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
4437 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
4438 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004439
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004440General rules:
4441--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004442
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004443(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
4444 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
4445 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
4446 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004447
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004448(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004449 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004450 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
4451 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004452
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004453Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
4454=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004455
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004456Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004457such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
4458"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004459
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004460Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
4461MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
4462"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004463
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004464If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
4465in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
4466ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
4467variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004468
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004469o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
4470 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004471
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004472o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
4473 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
4474 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004475
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004476o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
4477 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004478
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004479o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
4480 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
4481 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004482
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004483o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
4484 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004485
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004486If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004487will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004488may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
4489The naming convention is as follows:
4490"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004491
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004492Image Formats:
4493==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004494
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01004495U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
4496images in two formats:
4497
4498New uImage format (FIT)
4499-----------------------
4500
4501Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
4502to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
4503components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
4504SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
4505
4506
4507Old uImage format
4508-----------------
4509
4510Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
4511preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
4512details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004513
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004514* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
4515 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05004516 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
4517 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
4518 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02004519* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004520 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
4521 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004522* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
4523* Load Address
4524* Entry Point
4525* Image Name
4526* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004527
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004528The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
4529and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
4530CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004531
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004532
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004533Linux Support:
4534==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004535
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004536Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
4537easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
4538U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004539
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004540U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
4541special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
4542"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
4543instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
4544serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004545
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004546- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
4547 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
4548 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004549
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004550- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
4551 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004552
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004553- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
4554 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
4555 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
4556 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
4557 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
4558 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004559
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004560
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004561Linux HOWTO:
4562============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004563
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004564Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
4565---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004566
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004567U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
4568configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
4569(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
4570Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004571
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004572But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004573
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004574Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
4575include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02004576Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
4577and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004578as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004579
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004580
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004581Configuring the Linux kernel:
4582-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004583
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004584No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
4585device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004586
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004587
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004588Building a Linux Image:
4589-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004590
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004591With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
4592not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
4593"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
4594U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
4595which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
4596100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004597
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004598Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004599
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004600 make TQM850L_config
4601 make oldconfig
4602 make dep
4603 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004604
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004605The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
4606encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
4607CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004608
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004609* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004610
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004611* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004612
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004613 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
4614 -R .note -R .comment \
4615 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004616
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004617* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004618
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004619 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004620
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004621* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004622
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004623 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
4624 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
4625 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004626
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004627
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004628The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
4629with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
4630combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
4631byte header containing information about target architecture,
4632operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
4633stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004634
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004635"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
4636print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004637
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004638In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
4639contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
4640checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004641
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004642 tools/mkimage -l image
4643 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004644
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004645The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
4646from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004647
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004648 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
4649 -n name -d data_file image
4650 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
4651 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
4652 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4653 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
4654 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
4655 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
4656 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
4657 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004658
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00004659Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
4660address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
4661kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004662
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004663- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
4664- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004665
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004666So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004667
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004668 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4669 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004670 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004671 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
4672 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4673 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4674 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4675 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4676 Load Address: 0x00000000
4677 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004678
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004679To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004680
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004681 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
4682 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4683 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4684 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4685 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4686 Load Address: 0x00000000
4687 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004688
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004689NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
4690speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
4691needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
4692need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004693
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004694 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004695 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4696 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004697 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004698 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
4699 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4700 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4701 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
4702 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
4703 Load Address: 0x00000000
4704 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004705
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004706
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004707Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
4708when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004709
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004710 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
4711 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
4712 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
4713 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4714 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
4715 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4716 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
4717 Load Address: 0x00000000
4718 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004719
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004720
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004721Installing a Linux Image:
4722-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004723
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004724To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
4725you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004726
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004727 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004728
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004729The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
4730image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
4731address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
4732specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
4733command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004734
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004735Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
4736TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004737
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004738 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004739
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004740 .......... done
4741 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004742
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004743 => loads 40100000
4744 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4745 ~>examples/image.srec
4746 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
4747 ...
4748 15989 15990 15991 15992
4749 [file transfer complete]
4750 [connected]
4751 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004752
4753
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004754You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004755this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004756corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004757
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004758 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004759
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004760 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4761 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4762 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4763 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4764 Load Address: 00000000
4765 Entry Point: 0000000c
4766 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004767
4768
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004769Boot Linux:
4770-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004771
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004772The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
4773memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
4774of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
4775parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
4776"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004777
4778
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004779 => printenv bootargs
4780 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004781
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004782 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004783
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004784 => printenv bootargs
4785 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004786
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004787 => bootm 40020000
4788 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
4789 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
4790 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4791 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
4792 Load Address: 00000000
4793 Entry Point: 0000000c
4794 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4795 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4796 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
4797 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
4798 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4799 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4800 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
4801 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004802
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004803If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004804the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
4805format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004806
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004807 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004808
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004809 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4810 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4811 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4812 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4813 Load Address: 00000000
4814 Entry Point: 0000000c
4815 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004816
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004817 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
4818 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4819 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4820 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4821 Load Address: 00000000
4822 Entry Point: 00000000
4823 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004824
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004825 => bootm 40100000 40200000
4826 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
4827 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4828 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4829 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4830 Load Address: 00000000
4831 Entry Point: 0000000c
4832 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4833 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4834 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
4835 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4836 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4837 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4838 Load Address: 00000000
4839 Entry Point: 00000000
4840 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4841 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
4842 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
4843 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
4844 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4845 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4846 ...
4847 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
4848 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004849
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004850 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004851
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004852Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
4853-----------
4854
4855First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
4856titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
4857following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
4858flat device tree:
4859
4860=> print oftaddr
4861oftaddr=0x300000
4862=> print oft
4863oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
4864=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
4865Speed: 1000, full duplex
4866Using TSEC0 device
4867TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
4868Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
4869Load address: 0x300000
4870Loading: #
4871done
4872Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
4873=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
4874Speed: 1000, full duplex
4875Using TSEC0 device
4876TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
4877Filename 'uImage'.
4878Load address: 0x200000
4879Loading:############
4880done
4881Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
4882=> print loadaddr
4883loadaddr=200000
4884=> print oftaddr
4885oftaddr=0x300000
4886=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
4887## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004888 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
4889 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4890 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004891 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004892 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004893 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4894 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4895Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
4896Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
4897Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
4898[snip]
4899
4900
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004901More About U-Boot Image Types:
4902------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004903
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004904U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004905
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004906 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
4907 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
4908 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
4909 the Standalone Program.
4910 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
4911 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
4912 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
4913 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
4914 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
4915 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
4916 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
4917 being started.
4918 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
4919 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
4920 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
4921 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
4922 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
4923 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004924
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004925 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
4926 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
4927 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
4928 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
4929 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
4930 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004931
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004932 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
4933 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
4934 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004935
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004936 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
4937 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
4938 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
4939 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004940
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004941Booting the Linux zImage:
4942-------------------------
4943
4944On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
4945using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
4946as the syntax of "bootm" command.
4947
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00004948Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_INITRD_RAW allows user to supply
4949kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
4950address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
4951format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
4952
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004953
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004954Standalone HOWTO:
4955=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004956
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004957One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
4958run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
4959U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004960
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004961Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004962
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004963"Hello World" Demo:
4964-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004965
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004966'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
4967application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
4968It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
4969like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004970
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004971 => loads
4972 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4973 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
4974 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4975 [file transfer complete]
4976 [connected]
4977 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004978
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004979 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
4980 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4981 Hello World
4982 argc = 7
4983 argv[0] = "40004"
4984 argv[1] = "Hello"
4985 argv[2] = "World!"
4986 argv[3] = "This"
4987 argv[4] = "is"
4988 argv[5] = "a"
4989 argv[6] = "test."
4990 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
4991 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004992
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004993 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004994
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004995Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
4996handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
4997Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
4998The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
4999character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
5000controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005001
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005002 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
5003 b - enable interrupts and start timer
5004 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
5005 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005006
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005007 => loads
5008 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5009 ~>examples/timer.srec
5010 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
5011 [file transfer complete]
5012 [connected]
5013 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005014
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005015 => go 40004
5016 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
5017 TIMERS=0xfff00980
5018 Using timer 1
5019 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005020
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005021Hit 'b':
5022 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
5023 Enabling timer
5024Hit '?':
5025 [q, b, e, ?] ........
5026 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
5027Hit '?':
5028 [q, b, e, ?] .
5029 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
5030Hit '?':
5031 [q, b, e, ?] .
5032 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
5033Hit '?':
5034 [q, b, e, ?] .
5035 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
5036Hit 'e':
5037 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
5038Hit 'q':
5039 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005040
5041
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005042Minicom warning:
5043================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00005044
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005045Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
5046"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
5047consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
5048Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
5049especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00005050use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
5051http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
5052for help with kermit.
5053
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00005054
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005055Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
5056configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005057
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005058 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
5059 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
5060 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005061
5062
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005063NetBSD Notes:
5064=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005065
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005066Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
5067(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005068
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005069Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
5070NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
5071need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
5072Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
5073attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
5074missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005075
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005076 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
5077 # mkdir powerpc
5078 # ln -s powerpc machine
5079 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
5080 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005081
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005082Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
5083and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005084
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005085Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
5086stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
5087proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
5088tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00005089meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005090
5091
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005092Implementation Internals:
5093=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005094
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005095The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
5096implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
5097inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
5098hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005099
5100
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005101Initial Stack, Global Data:
5102---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005103
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005104The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
5105starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
5106system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
5107This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
5108is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
5109at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
5110options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
5111models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
5112MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
5113locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005114
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005115 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005116 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005117
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005118 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
5119 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
5120 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
5121 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005122
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005123 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
5124 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
5125 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
5126 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
5127 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005128 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005129 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
5130 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005131
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005132 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
5133 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005134 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005135 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
5136 board designers haven't used it for something that would
5137 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
5138 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005139
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005140 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005141 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
5142 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02005143 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005144 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
5145 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
5146 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
5147 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
5148 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005149
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005150 -Chris Hallinan
5151 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005152
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005153It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
5154code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005155
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005156* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
5157 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005158
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005159* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005160 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
5161 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005162
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005163* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
5164 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005165
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005166Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
5167normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
5168turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
5169simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
5170functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
5171functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
5172the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
5173place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
5174reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005175
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005176When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
5177relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
5178GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005179
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005180For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
5181 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01005182 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005183 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
5184 R5-R10: parameter passing
5185 R13: small data area pointer
5186 R30: GOT pointer
5187 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005188
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01005189 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
5190 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
5191 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005192
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01005193 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005194
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005195 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
5196 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
5197 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
5198 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
5199 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
5200 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005201
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00005202On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05005203 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
5204
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00005205 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05005206
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005207On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005208
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005209 R0: function argument word/integer result
5210 R1-R3: function argument word
5211 R9: GOT pointer
5212 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking if enabled)
5213 R11: argument (frame) pointer
5214 R12: temporary workspace
5215 R13: stack pointer
5216 R14: link register
5217 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005218
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005219 ==> U-Boot will use R8 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005220
Thomas Chou0df01fd2010-05-21 11:08:03 +08005221On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
5222 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
5223
5224 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
5225
5226 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
5227 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
5228
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005229On NDS32, the following registers are used:
5230
5231 R0-R1: argument/return
5232 R2-R5: argument
5233 R15: temporary register for assembler
5234 R16: trampoline register
5235 R28: frame pointer (FP)
5236 R29: global pointer (GP)
5237 R30: link register (LP)
5238 R31: stack pointer (SP)
5239 PC: program counter (PC)
5240
5241 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
5242
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02005243NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
5244or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005245
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005246Memory Management:
5247------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005248
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005249U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
5250MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005251
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005252The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
5253controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
5254memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
5255physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005256
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005257U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
5258TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
5259booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
5260to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005261memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005262configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
5263Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005264
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005265Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
5266of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005267
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005268So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
5269this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005270
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005271 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
5272 :
5273 0x0000 1FFF
5274 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
5275 :
5276 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005277
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005278 :
5279 :
5280 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
5281 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
5282 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
5283 :
5284 0x00FD FFFF
5285 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
5286 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
5287 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
5288 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005289
5290
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005291System Initialization:
5292----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005293
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005294In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005295(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005296configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
5297To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
5298To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
5299initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
5300which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
5301part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
5302the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005303
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005304Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
5305preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
5306(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
5307on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
5308programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
5309simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
5310banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005311
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005312When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
5313different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
5314bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
53150x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
5316contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005317
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005318Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
5319and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
5320Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
5321pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005322
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005323Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
5324until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
5325running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
5326new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005327
5328
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005329U-Boot Porting Guide:
5330----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005331
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005332[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
5333list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005334
5335
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005336int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005337{
5338 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005339
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005340 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
5341 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005342
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005343 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005344 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005345 return 0;
5346 }
5347
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005348 Download latest U-Boot source;
5349
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005350 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005351
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005352 if (clueless)
5353 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005354
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005355 while (learning) {
5356 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005357 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
5358 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005359 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005360 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005361 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005362
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005363 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
5364 Buy a BDI3000;
5365 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005366 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005367
5368 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
5369 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
5370 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
5371 } else {
5372 Create your own board support subdirectory;
5373 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005374 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005375 Edit new board/<myboard> files
5376 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005377
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005378 while (!accepted) {
5379 while (!running) {
5380 do {
5381 Add / modify source code;
5382 } until (compiles);
5383 Debug;
5384 if (clueless)
5385 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
5386 }
5387 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
5388 if (reasonable critiques)
5389 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
5390 else
5391 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005392 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005393
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005394 return 0;
5395}
5396
5397void no_more_time (int sig)
5398{
5399 hire_a_guru();
5400}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005401
5402
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005403Coding Standards:
5404-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005405
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005406All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005407coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005408"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005409
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005410Source files originating from a different project (for example the
5411MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
5412reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
5413sources.
5414
5415Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
5416Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
5417in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005418
5419Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
5420- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005421- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005422- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005423- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005424- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
5425
5426Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
5427with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005428
5429
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005430Submitting Patches:
5431-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005432
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005433Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
5434establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
5435may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005436
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02005437Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005438
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005439Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
5440see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
5441
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005442When you send a patch, please include the following information with
5443it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005444
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005445* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
5446 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
5447 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005448
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005449* For new features: a description of the feature and your
5450 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005451
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005452* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
5453
5454* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
5455
5456* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add this
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005457 board to the MAINTAINERS file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005458
5459* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
5460 document these in the README file.
5461
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005462* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
5463 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005464 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005465 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
5466 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005467
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005468 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
5469 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
5470 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005471
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005472 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
5473 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
5474 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
5475 affected files).
5476
5477 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
5478 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005479
5480* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
5481 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
5482
5483* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
5484 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
5485
5486
5487Notes:
5488
5489* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
5490 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
5491 for any of the boards.
5492
5493* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
5494 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
5495 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
5496
5497* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
5498 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
5499 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
5500 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
5501 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
5502 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00005503
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005504* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
5505 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
5506 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
5507 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.